blob: ef01cced876f60f1d19e3deaa8da7498180f5b0d [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000060 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
61 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000062
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000064 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
65 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
66 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
67 else
68 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000069 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000070 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
71 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000072
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000073 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000074 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
76 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
77 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
78 return true;
79 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000080 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000081
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000082 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000083}
84
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000085/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000087/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
88///
89void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000090 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000091 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000094
95 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
96 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000097 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
98 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000099
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000100 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
101 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000102 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000103 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
104 int isMethod = 0;
105 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
106 // skip over named parameters.
107 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
108 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
109 if (nullPos)
110 --nullPos;
111 else
112 ++i;
113 }
114 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
115 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000116 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000117 // skip over named parameters.
118 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
119 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
120 if (nullPos)
121 --nullPos;
122 else
123 ++i;
124 }
125 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000126 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000127 // block or function pointer call.
128 QualType Ty = V->getType();
129 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000130 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000131 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
132 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000133 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
134 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
135 unsigned k;
136 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
137 if (nullPos)
138 --nullPos;
139 else
140 ++i;
141 }
142 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
143 }
144 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
145 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000146 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000147 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 return;
150
151 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000152 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000153 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000154 return;
155 }
156 int sentinel = i;
157 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
158 --sentinelPos;
159 ++i;
160 }
161 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
162 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000163 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000164 return;
165 }
166 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
167 ++i;
168 ++sentinel;
169 }
170 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
172 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
173 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000174 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000175 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
176 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
177 return;
178
179 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
180 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
181
182 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
183 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000184}
185
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000186SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
187 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
188 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
189}
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
192// Standard Promotions and Conversions
193//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
194
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000195/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
196void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
197 QualType Ty = E->getType();
198 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
199
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000200 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000201 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000202 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000203 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
204 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
205 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
206 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
207 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
208 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
209 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000210 //
211 // C++ 4.2p1:
212 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
213 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
214 //
215 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
216 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000217 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000218 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000219 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000220}
221
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000224
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000225 QualType Ty = E->getType();
226 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
227 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
228 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
229 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
230 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
231 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
232 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
233 // rvalue is T
234 //
235 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000236 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
237 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000238 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240 }
241}
242
243
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000244/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
247/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
248/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
249Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
250 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
251 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000252
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000253 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
254 //
255 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
256 // unsigned int may be used:
257 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
258 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
259 // and unsigned int.
260 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
261 //
262 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
263 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
264 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
265 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000266 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
267 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000268 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000269 return Expr;
270 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000272 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000273 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000274 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000275 }
276
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000277 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000278 return Expr;
279}
280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000282/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000283/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
284void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
285 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
286 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000287
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000288 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000289 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
290 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000292
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000293 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
294}
295
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000296/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
297/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
298/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
299/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
301 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000302 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000303
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000304 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
305 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
306 // etc.
307 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
308 return false;
309
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000310 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
312 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
313 << Expr->getType() << CT))
314 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000315
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000316 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000317 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000318 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
319 << Expr->getType() << CT))
320 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000321
322 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000323}
324
325
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
327/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000328/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000329/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
330/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
331/// GCC.
332QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
333 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000334 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000335 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000336
337 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000340 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000341 QualType lhs =
342 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000343 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000344 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000345
346 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
347 if (lhs == rhs)
348 return lhs;
349
350 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
351 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
352 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
353 return lhs;
354
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000355 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000356 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000357 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
358 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000359 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000360 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
361 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
362
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000363 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000364 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000365 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
366 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367 return destType;
368}
369
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000370//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
371// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
372//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
373
374
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
377/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
378/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
379/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000381ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000382Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
384
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000385 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000386 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000387 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000388
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000389 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000390 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
391 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000393 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000394 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000395 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396
397 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000398 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000399 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000400
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000401 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
402 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
403 // strings.
404 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000405 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000406 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000407
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000408 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000409 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
410 Literal.GetStringLength(),
411 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
412 &StringTokLocs[0],
413 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000414}
415
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000416/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
417/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
418/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
419/// for values inside the block or for globals).
420///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000421/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000422/// up-to-date.
423///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000424static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000425 ValueDecl *VD) {
426 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
427 // we wanted to.
428 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
429 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000430
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000431 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
432 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
433 return false;
434
435 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
436 // snapshot it.
437 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
438 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000439 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
440 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
443 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
444
445 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
446 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
447 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
448 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000449 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
450 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000451
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000452 if (!NextBlock)
453 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000454
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000455 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
456 // having a reference outside it.
457 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
458 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
461 // a snapshot as well.
462 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
463 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000464
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000465 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000466}
467
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000468
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000469ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000470Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000471 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000472 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
473 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
474}
475
476/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000477ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
479 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
480 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000481 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000482 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000484 << D->getDeclName();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000487
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000488 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
490 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
491 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000492 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000493 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
495 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
497 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000498 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000500 << D->getIdentifier();
501 return ExprError();
502 }
503 }
504 }
505 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000506
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000507 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000508
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000509 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
510 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
511 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000512 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000513}
514
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000515/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
516/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
517/// actual member.
518///
519/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
520/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
521/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
522/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
523/// we found.
524///
525/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
526/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
527/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
528VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
529 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000530 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
531 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
532 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
533
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
536 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
537 do {
538 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000539 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000540 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000542 else {
543 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
544 break;
545 }
546 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000547 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000549
550 return BaseObject;
551}
552
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000553ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000554Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
555 FieldDecl *Field,
556 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
557 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
558 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000559 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 AnonFields);
561
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
563 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
564 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
565 // found via name lookup.
566 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 if (BaseObject) {
569 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
570 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000571 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000572 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000573 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000574 BaseQuals
575 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000576 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
577 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
578 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
579 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
580 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000581 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000582 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
583 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
584 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 BaseQuals
586 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000587 } else {
588 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
589 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
590 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000591 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
592 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000593 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 = Context.getTagDeclType(
596 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
597 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000598 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000599 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
600 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
601 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000602 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000603 MD->getThisType(Context),
604 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
606 }
607 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000612 }
613
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000614 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000615 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
616 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 }
618
619 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
620 // anonymous struct/union.
621 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000622 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
624 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
625 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
626 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000627 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
628 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
629
630 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
631 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
632 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
633 ResultQuals.removeConst();
634
635 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
636 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
637
638 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
639 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
640
641 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
642 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
643 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
644
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000645 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000646 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000647 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000648 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
649 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000650 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000651 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652 }
653
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000654 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000655}
656
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000657/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000658/// possibly a list of template arguments.
659///
660/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
661/// DecomposeTemplateName.
662///
663/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
664/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
665/// some way.
666static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
667 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
668 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000669 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000670 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
671 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
672 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
673 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
674
675 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
676 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
677 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
678 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
679 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
680
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000681 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
683 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
685 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000686 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 TemplateArgs = 0;
688 }
689}
690
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
692/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
693/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000695 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
696 return false;
697
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000698 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
699 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
700 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
701 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
702 if (!BaseRT) return false;
703
704 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000705 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
707 return false;
708 }
709
710 return true;
711}
712
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000713/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
714/// the prospective base classes.
715static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
716 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
717 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719 return false;
720
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000721 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000722 if (!RD) return false;
723 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
724
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
726 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
727 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
728 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
729 if (!BaseRT) return false;
730
731 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000738
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739enum IMAKind {
740 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
741 IMA_Static,
742
743 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
744 IMA_Mixed,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
748 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
749
750 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
751 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
752 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
753
754 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
755 IMA_Instance,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
758 IMA_Unresolved,
759
760 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
761 /// context is not an instance method.
762 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
763
764 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
765 /// non-class context.
766 IMA_AnonymousMember,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
769 /// context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
771
772 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
773 /// class.
774 IMA_Error_Unrelated
775};
776
777/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
778/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
779/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
780/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
781/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
782/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
783static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
784 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000785 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000786
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000787 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000788 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000789 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
790 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000791
792 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
793 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
794
795 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
796 bool hasNonInstance = false;
797 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
798 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000799 NamedDecl *D = *I;
800 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000801 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
802
803 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
804 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
805 // that's a special case.
806 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
807 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
808 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
809 }
810 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
811 }
812 else
813 hasNonInstance = true;
814 }
815
816 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
817 // member reference.
818 if (Classes.empty())
819 return IMA_Static;
820
821 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
822 // an implicit member reference.
823 if (isStaticContext)
824 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
825
826 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
827 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
828 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
829 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000830 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000831 Classes))
832 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
833
834 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
835}
836
837/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
838static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
839 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
840 const LookupResult &R) {
841 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
842 SourceRange Range(Loc);
843 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
844
845 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
846 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
847 if (MD->isStatic()) {
848 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
850 << Range << R.getLookupName();
851 return;
852 }
853 }
854
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
856 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
857 return;
858 }
859
860 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000861}
862
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000863/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
864///
865/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000866bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
867 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
869
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000870 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000871 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
873 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000874 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000876 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
877 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000879 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
880 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
881 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
882 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000883 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000884 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
886 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
887
888 if (!R.empty()) {
889 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
890 R.suppressDiagnostics();
891
892 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
893 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
894 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
895 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
896
897 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
898 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
899 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
902 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000903 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000904 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000905 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000906 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
907 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
908 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
909 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
910 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
911 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
912 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
913 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
914 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
915 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
916 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
917 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
918 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
919 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
922 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000924 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000925 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000926 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928
929 // Do we really want to note all of these?
930 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
931 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
932
933 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
934 return false;
935 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000936
937 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000938 }
939 }
940
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000941 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000942 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000943 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000944 if (!R.empty()) {
945 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 if (SS.isEmpty())
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
949 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
952 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
953 << SS.getRange()
954 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
955 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
956 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
957 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
958 << ND->getDeclName();
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
965 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
966 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
967 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
968 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
969 // to recover well anyway.
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange();
976
977 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
978 return true;
979 }
980 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000985 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
988 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 return true;
990 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000991 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000992 }
993
994 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
995 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
996 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
999 << SS.getRange();
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001003 // Give up, we can't recover.
1004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1005 return true;
1006}
1007
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II,
1010 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001011 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1012 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1013 if (!IDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1016 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1019 if (!property)
1020 return 0;
1021 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1022 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1023 return 0;
1024 return property;
1025}
1026
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II,
1030 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1031 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001032 bool LookForIvars;
1033 if (Lookup.empty())
1034 LookForIvars = true;
1035 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1036 LookForIvars = false;
1037 else
1038 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1039 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1040 if (!LookForIvars)
1041 return 0;
1042
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001043 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1044 if (!IDecl)
1045 return 0;
1046 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001047 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1048 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001049 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1050 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1051 if (!property)
1052 return 0;
1053 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1054 DynamicImplSeen =
1055 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1056 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001057 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1058 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001059 NameLoc,
1060 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1061 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1062 (Expr *)0, true);
1063 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1064 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1065 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1066 return Ivar;
1067 }
1068 return 0;
1069}
1070
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001071ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001072 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1073 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1074 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1075 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1077 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1078
1079 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001081
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001082 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083
1084 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001088
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001089 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001090 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001091 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001092
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1094 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001095 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1096 // (note: handled after lookup)
1097 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1098 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1099 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001100 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1101 // names a dependent type.
1102 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1103 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001104 bool DependentID = false;
1105 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1106 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1107 DependentID = true;
1108 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1109 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1110 if (DC) {
1111 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1112 return ExprError();
1113 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1114 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1115 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1116 } else {
1117 DependentID = true;
1118 }
1119 }
1120
1121 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001122 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 TemplateArgs);
1124 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001125 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001127 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001128 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001129 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1130 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1131 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1132 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1133 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001134 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1135 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1136 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001138 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001140
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1142 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001143 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001144 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 if (E.isInvalid())
1146 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001147
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1149 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001150 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1151 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001152 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001153 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1154 isAddressOfOperand);
1155 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001156 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1157 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001158 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001159 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001160
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001161 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1162 return ExprError();
1163
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001164 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1165 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001169 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1171 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1172 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1173 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1174 }
1175
1176 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1177 // call, diagnose the problem.
1178 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001179 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001180 return ExprError();
1181
1182 assert(!R.empty() &&
1183 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184
1185 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1186 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001187 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001188 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1189 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001190 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001191 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1192 return move(E);
1193 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001194 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001195 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001196
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001197 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1198 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1199
1200 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001201 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001202 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1203 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001204 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1205 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1206 if (Property) {
1207 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1208 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001209 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001210 }
1211 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001212 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001213 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1214 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1215 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1216 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1217 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1218 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001219 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001220 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001221
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001222 QualType T = Func->getType();
1223 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001224 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001225 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1226 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001227 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001228 }
1229 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001230
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001231 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001232 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1233 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1234 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1235 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1236 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1237 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1238 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1239 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001240 //
1241 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1242 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1243 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1244 // non-static member function:
1245 //
1246 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1247 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1248 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1249 // member function call.
1250 //
1251 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1252 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1253 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1254 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001255 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001256 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1257 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1259 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1261 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1262 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001263 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1264 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001265 else
1266 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1267
1268 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001269 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001270 }
1271
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 if (TemplateArgs)
1273 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001274
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1276}
1277
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001278/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001279ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001280Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1281 LookupResult &R,
1282 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1283 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1284 case IMA_Instance:
1285 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1286
1287 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1288 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1289 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1290 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1291
1292 case IMA_Mixed:
1293 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1294 case IMA_Unresolved:
1295 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1296
1297 case IMA_Static:
1298 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1299 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1300 if (TemplateArgs)
1301 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1303
1304 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1305 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1306 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1307 return ExprError();
1308 }
1309
1310 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1311 return ExprError();
1312}
1313
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001314/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1315/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1316/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1317/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001318ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001319Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001320 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001322 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001323 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001325 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001326 return ExprError();
1327
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001328 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1330
1331 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1332 return ExprError();
1333
1334 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001335 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1336 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001337 return ExprError();
1338 }
1339
1340 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1341}
1342
1343/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1344/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1345/// additional lookup.
1346///
1347/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1348/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1349///
1350/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001351ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001352Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001353 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001355 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001356
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1358 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1359 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1360 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1361 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1362
1363 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1364 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1365 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001366 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367
1368 bool LookForIvars;
1369 if (Lookup.empty())
1370 LookForIvars = true;
1371 else if (IsClassMethod)
1372 LookForIvars = false;
1373 else
1374 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1375 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1380 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1381 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1382 if (IsClassMethod)
1383 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1384 << IV->getDeclName());
1385
1386 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1387 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1388 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1389 return ExprError();
1390
1391 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1392 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1393 return ExprError();
1394
1395 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1396 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1397 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1398 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1399
1400 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1401 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1402 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1403 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001404 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001405 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001406 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001407 SelfName, false, false);
1408 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1409 return ExprError();
1410
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001411 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1412 return Owned(new (Context)
1413 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1414 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1415 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001416 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001417 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001419 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1420 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1421 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1422 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1424 }
1425 }
1426
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001427 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1428 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1429 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1430 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1431 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1432 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1433 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1434 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1435 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1436 }
1437 }
1438 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001439 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1440 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001441}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001442
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001443/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1444///
1445/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1446///
1447/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1448/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1449/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1450/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1451///
1452/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1453/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1454/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1455/// the class declaring the member.
1456///
1457/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1458/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1459/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001460bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1462 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464 NamedDecl *Member) {
1465 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1466 if (!RD)
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 QualType DestRecordType;
1470 QualType DestType;
1471 QualType FromRecordType;
1472 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1473 bool PointerConversions = false;
1474 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1475 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001477 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1478 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1479 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1480 PointerConversions = true;
1481 } else {
1482 DestType = DestRecordType;
1483 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001484 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1486 if (Method->isStatic())
1487 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001488
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1490 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1493 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1494 PointerConversions = true;
1495 } else {
1496 FromRecordType = FromType;
1497 DestType = DestRecordType;
1498 }
1499 } else {
1500 // No conversion necessary.
1501 return false;
1502 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1505 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1508 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1509 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001511 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1512 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1513
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001514 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001515
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001518 // class name.
1519 //
1520 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1521 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1522 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1523 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1524 //
1525 // class Base { public: int x; };
1526 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1527 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1528 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1529 //
1530 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1531 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1532 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1533 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1536 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1537 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1538
1539 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1540
1541 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1542 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1543 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1544 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001545 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001547 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 return true;
1549
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001552 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1553 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554
1555 FromType = QType;
1556 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1557
1558 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1559 // we're done.
1560 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1561 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 }
1563 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001564
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001565 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001566
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001567 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1568 // down to the using declaration's type.
1569 //
1570 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1571 // class ever has member declarations.
1572 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1573 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1574 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1575 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1576
1577 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1578 // conversion is non-trivial.
1579 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1580 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001581 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001582 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001583 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001585
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001586 QualType UType = URecordType;
1587 if (PointerConversions)
1588 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001589 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001590 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001591 FromType = UType;
1592 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1593 }
1594
1595 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1596 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1597 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001598 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001599
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001600 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001601 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1602 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001603 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001604 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001605
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001606 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001607 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001608 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001609}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001610
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001611/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001612static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001613 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001614 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001615 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1616 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1618 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1619 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001620 if (SS.isSet()) {
1621 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1622 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001626 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1627 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001628}
1629
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001630/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1631/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1632/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1633/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001634ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001635Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1636 LookupResult &R,
1637 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1638 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1640
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001641 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001642
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001643 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1644 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001645 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001648 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001650
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001651 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1652 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001653 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1654 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001655 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1656 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001657 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1658 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1659 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1660 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001661 }
1662
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001663 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001664 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1665 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001666 SS,
1667 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1668 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669}
1670
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 const LookupResult &R,
1673 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1675 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1676 return false;
1677
1678 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 return false;
1681
1682 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684 return false;
1685
1686 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1687 // normal lookup:
1688 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1689 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a declaration of a class member
1693 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1694 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001695 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696 return false;
1697
1698 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1699 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1700 // using-declaration
1701 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1702 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1703 // turn off ADL anyway).
1704 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1705 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1706 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1707 return false;
1708
1709 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1710 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1711 // template
1712 // And also for builtin functions.
1713 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1714 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1715
1716 // But also builtin functions.
1717 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1718 return false;
1719 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1720 return false;
1721 }
1722
1723 return true;
1724}
1725
1726
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1728/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1729/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1730/// will in fact be used.
1731static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1732 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1733 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1734 return true;
1735 }
1736
1737 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1738 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1739 return true;
1740 }
1741
1742 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1743 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1744 return true;
1745 }
1746
1747 return false;
1748}
1749
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001750ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001751Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001752 LookupResult &R,
1753 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001754 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1755 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001756 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001757 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1758 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759
1760 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1761 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1762 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001763 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1764 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 return ExprError();
1766
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001767 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1768 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1769 // we've picked a target.
1770 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1771
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001772 bool Dependent
1773 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001775 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001776 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001777 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001778 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1779 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001780
1781 return Owned(ULE);
1782}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001783
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784
1785/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001786ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001787Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001788 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1789 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001790 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001791 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1792 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001793
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001794 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001795 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1796 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001797
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001798 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1799 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1800 // a template argument list.
1801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1802 << Template << SS.getRange();
1803 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1804 return ExprError();
1805 }
1806
1807 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1808 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1809 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001811 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001812 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001813 return ExprError();
1814 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001816 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1817 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1818 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1819 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001821 return ExprError();
1822
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001823 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1824 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001825 return ExprError();
1826
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001827 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1828 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1829 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1830 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001831 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001832 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1833 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1834 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001835 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001836 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001837 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1840 return ExprError();
1841 }
1842
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001843 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001844 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1845 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1846 return ExprError();
1847 }
1848
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001849 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001850 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001851 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001852 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001853 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001854 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1855 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001856 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001858 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001859 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001860 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1861 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001862 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1864 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1865 Expr *E = new (Context)
1866 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1867 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001868
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001869 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001870 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001871 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001872 SourceLocation(),
1873 Owned(E));
1874 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001875 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001876 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1877 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1878 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001879 }
1880 }
1881 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001882 }
1883 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1884 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001885
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001886 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1887 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001888}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001889
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001890ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001891 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001892 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001894 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001895 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001896 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1897 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1898 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001899 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001900
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001901 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1902 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001904 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001905 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1906 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001907 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001908 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001909 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001910 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001912 QualType ResTy;
1913 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1914 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1915 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001916 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001918 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001919 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001920 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1921 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001922 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001923}
1924
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001925ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001926 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001927 bool Invalid = false;
1928 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1929 if (Invalid)
1930 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001932 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1933 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001934 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001936
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 QualType Ty;
1938 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1939 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1940 else if (Literal.isWide())
1941 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001942 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1943 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001944 else
1945 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001946
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001947 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1948 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001949 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001950}
1951
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001954 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1955 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001956 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001957 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001958 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001959 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001960 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001961
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001962 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001963 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1964 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001965 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001967 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001968 bool Invalid = false;
1969 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1970 if (Invalid)
1971 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001973 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001974 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001975 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 return ExprError();
1977
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001978 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001980 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001981 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001982 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001983 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001984 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001985 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001986 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001987 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001988
1989 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1990
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001991 using llvm::APFloat;
1992 APFloat Val(Format);
1993
1994 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001995
1996 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1997 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1998 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1999 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002001 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002002 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002003 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002004 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2005 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002006 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002007 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2008 }
2009
2010 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2011 << Ty
2012 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2013 }
2014
2015 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002016 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002017
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002018 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002020 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002021 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002023 // long long is a C99 feature.
2024 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002025 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2027
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002028 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2032 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002034 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2035 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002036 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002037 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002038 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2039 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002041 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2042 // be an unsigned int.
2043 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2044
2045 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002047 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2048 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002050
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2052 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2053 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2054 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002055 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002056 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002059 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002062 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002066 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2067 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2068 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2069 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002070 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002071 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002075 }
2076
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002077 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002079 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002080
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002081 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2082 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2083 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2084 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 }
2090 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002091
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002092 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2093 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002094 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002095 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002096 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002098 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002099
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2101 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002102 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002103 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002104 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002105
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002106 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2107 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002108 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002109 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002110
2111 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002112}
2113
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002114ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002115 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002116 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002117 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002118}
2119
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002120/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002121/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002122bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002123 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002124 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002125 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002126 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2127 return false;
2128
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002129 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2130 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2131 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2132 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2133 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2134 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2135
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002136 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002137 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 if (isSizeof)
2140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002145 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2147 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002148 return false;
2149 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002150
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002152 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2153 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002154 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002156 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002157 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002159 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2160 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002161 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002163 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002164}
2165
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002166static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2167 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002168 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002169
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002171 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2172 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002173
2174 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2175 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2176 return false;
2177
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002178 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002179 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002180 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002181 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002182
2183 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2184 // bit-field.
2185 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002186 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002187 return false;
2188
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002189 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002190}
2191
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002192/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002193ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002194Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002195 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002196 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002197 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002198 return ExprError();
2199
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002201
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002202 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2203 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2204 return ExprError();
2205
2206 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002207 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002208 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2209 R.getEnd()));
2210}
2211
2212/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2213/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002214ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002215Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002216 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002217 ExprResult PResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2218 if (PResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2219 E = PResult.take();
2220
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002221 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2222 bool isInvalid = false;
2223 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2224 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2225 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002226 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002227 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002228 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2229 isInvalid = true;
2230 } else {
2231 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2232 }
2233
2234 if (isInvalid)
2235 return ExprError();
2236
2237 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2238 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2239 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2240 R.getEnd()));
2241}
2242
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002243/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2244/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2245/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002246ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002247Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2248 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002249 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002250 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002251
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002252 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002253 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002254 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002256 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002257
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002258 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002259 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002260 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2261
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002262 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002263}
2264
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002265QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002266 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2267 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002268
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002269 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002270 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002271 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002272
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002273 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2274 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2275 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002276
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002277 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002278 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2279 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002280 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002281}
2282
2283
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002284
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002285ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002286Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002287 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002288 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002289 switch (Kind) {
2290 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002291 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2292 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002293 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002294
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002295 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002296}
2297
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002298ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002299Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2300 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002301 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002302 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002303 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2304 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002305
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002306 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002307
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002308 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002309 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002310 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2311 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2312 }
2313
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002315 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002316 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2317 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2318 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002319 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002320 }
2321
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002322 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002323}
2324
2325
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002326ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002327Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2328 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2329 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2330 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002331
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002332 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002333 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2334 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2335 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002336
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002337 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002338
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002339 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002340 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002341 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002342 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002343 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2344 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002345 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2346 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2347 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2348 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002349 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002350 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2351 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002352 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002353 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002354 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002355 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2356 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002357 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002358 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002359 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002360 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2361 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2362 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002363 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002364 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002365 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2366 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2367 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2368 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002369 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002370 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002371 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002372
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002373 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2374 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002375 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2376 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002377 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002378 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2379 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2380 // force the promotion here.
2381 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2382 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002383 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002384 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002385 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2386
2387 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2388 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002389 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002390 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2391 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2392 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2393 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002394 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002395 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002396 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2397
2398 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2399 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002400 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002401 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002402 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2403 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002404 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002405 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002406 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002407 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2408 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002409
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002410 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002411 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2412 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002413 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2414
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002415 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2417 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002418 // incomplete types are not object types.
2419 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2420 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2421 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2422 return ExprError();
2423 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002425 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2426 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2427 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2428 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2429 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002430 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002431 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2432 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002433 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002434
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002435 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002436 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002437 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2438 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2439 return ExprError();
2440 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002441
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002442 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002443 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002444}
2445
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002446QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002447CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002448 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002449 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002450 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2451 // see FIXME there.
2452 //
2453 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2454 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002455 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002456
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002457 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002458 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002459
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002460 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002461 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2462 // to be selected.
2463 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002464
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002465 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2466 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002467 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002468
2469 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2470 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002471 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002472 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2473 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002474 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002475 do
2476 compStr++;
2477 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002478 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002479 do
2480 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002481 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002482 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002483
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002484 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002485 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2486 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002487 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002488 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002489 return QualType();
2490 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002491
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002492 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2493 // operates on.
2494 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002495 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002496
2497 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002498 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002499
2500 while (*compStr) {
2501 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2502 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2503 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2504 return QualType();
2505 }
2506 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002507 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002508
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002509 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002510 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002511 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002512 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002513 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002514 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002515 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002516 if (HexSwizzle)
2517 CompSize--;
2518
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002519 if (CompSize == 1)
2520 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002521
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002522 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002523 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002524 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2525 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2526 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2527 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002528 }
2529 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002530}
2531
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002532static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002533 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002534 const Selector &Sel,
2535 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002536 if (Member)
2537 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2538 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002539 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002540 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002541
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002542 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2543 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002544 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2545 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002546 return D;
2547 }
2548 return 0;
2549}
2550
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002551static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2552 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2553 const Selector &Sel,
2554 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002555 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2556 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002557 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002558 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002559 if (Member)
2560 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2561 GDecl = PD;
2562 break;
2563 }
2564 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002565 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 GDecl = OMD;
2567 break;
2568 }
2569 }
2570 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002571 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002572 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2573 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002574 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2575 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002576 if (GDecl)
2577 return GDecl;
2578 }
2579 }
2580 return GDecl;
2581}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002582
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002583ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002584Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002586 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2587 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002588 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002590 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2591 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2592 //
2593 // T* t;
2594 // t.f;
2595 //
2596 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2597 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2598 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2599 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002600 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002601 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2602 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002603 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002604 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002605 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606 return ExprError();
2607 }
2608 }
2609
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002610 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2611 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002612 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002613
2614 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2615 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002616 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002617 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002618 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002619 SS.getRange(),
2620 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002621 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002622}
2623
2624/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2625/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2626/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2627static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2628 Expr *BaseExpr,
2629 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002630 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002632 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2633 // diagnostics.
2634 if (!BaseExpr)
2635 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002637 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2638 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639}
2640
2641// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2642// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2643// type. The restriction here is:
2644//
2645// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2646// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2647// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2648//
2649// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2650// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2651// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2652// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2653bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2654 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002655 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002656 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2658 if (!BaseRT) {
2659 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2660 // dependent.
2661 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2662 return false;
2663 }
2664 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665
2666 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2668 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002669 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002673 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2674 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2675 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002676
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002677 if (!DC->isRecord())
2678 continue;
2679
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002681 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002682
2683 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2684 return false;
2685 }
2686
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002687 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 return true;
2689}
2690
2691static bool
2692LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2693 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002694 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2695 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2697 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002698 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699 << BaseRange))
2700 return true;
2701
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002702 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2703 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2704 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2705
2706 bool MOUS;
2707 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2708 return false;
2709 }
2710
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2712 if (SS.isSet()) {
2713 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2714 // nested-name-specifier.
2715 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2716
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002717 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002718 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2719 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2720 return true;
2721 }
2722
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002724
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002725 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2726 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2727 << DC << SS.getRange();
2728 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729 }
2730 }
2731
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2733 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002735 if (!R.empty())
2736 return false;
2737
2738 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2739 // for typos.
2740 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002741 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002742 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002743 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2744 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2745 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002746 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2747 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002748 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2749 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2750 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002751 return false;
2752 } else {
2753 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002754 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002755 }
2756
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002757 return false;
2758}
2759
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002760ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002761Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002762 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002763 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002765 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002766 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002767 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2768 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002769 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2771 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002772 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002773
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002774 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 // Implicit member accesses.
2777 if (!Base) {
2778 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2779 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2780 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2781 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002782 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002783 return ExprError();
2784
2785 // Explicit member accesses.
2786 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002787 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002788 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002789 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002790
2791 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2792 Owned(Base);
2793 return ExprError();
2794 }
2795
2796 if (Result.get())
2797 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002798
2799 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2800 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 }
2802
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002803 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002804 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2805 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806}
2807
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002808ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002809Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002810 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2811 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002812 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002813 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002814 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2815 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002816 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817 if (IsArrow) {
2818 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2819 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2820 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002821 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002823 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002824 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2825 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2826 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827
2828 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002829 return ExprError();
2830
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 if (R.empty()) {
2832 // Rederive where we looked up.
2833 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2834 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2835 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002836
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002838 << MemberName << DC
2839 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 return ExprError();
2841 }
2842
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002843 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2844 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2845 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2846 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2847 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2848 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2849 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2850 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2851 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2852 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002853 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002854 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 return ExprError();
2856
2857 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2858 // result.
2859 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002860 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002861 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002862 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002863 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002864
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002865 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2866 // pick a member.
2867 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2868
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2870 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2871 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002872 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2873 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002874 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002875 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002876 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877
2878 return Owned(MemExpr);
2879 }
2880
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002881 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002882 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2884
2885 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2886
2887 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2888 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2889 // error cases.
2890 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2891 return ExprError();
2892
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002893 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2894 if (!BaseExpr) {
2895 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002896 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002897 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002898
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002899 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2900 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2901 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2902 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002903 }
2904
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2906 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2907 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2908 // explicitly qualified.
2909 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2910 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2911 }
2912
2913 // Check the use of this member.
2914 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2915 Owned(BaseExpr);
2916 return ExprError();
2917 }
2918
2919 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2920 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2921 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002922 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2923 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002924 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2925 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2926
2927 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2928 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2929 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2930 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2931 else {
2932 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2933 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2934 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2935
2936 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2937 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2938
2939 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2940 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2941 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2942 }
2943
2944 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002945 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946 return ExprError();
2947 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002948 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2949 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950 }
2951
2952 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2953 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2954 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002955 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002956 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2957 }
2958
2959 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2960 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2961 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002962 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002963 MemberFn->getType()));
2964 }
2965
2966 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2967 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2968 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002969 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2970 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971 }
2972
2973 Owned(BaseExpr);
2974
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002975 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002976 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002977 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002978 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2979 else
2980 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2981 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002982
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002983 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2984 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002985 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002986 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987}
2988
2989/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2990/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2991/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2992/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2993/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2994/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2995/// an ordinary member expression.
2996///
2997/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2998/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002999ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003001 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003002 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003003 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003004 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003005
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003006 // Perform default conversions.
3007 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003008
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003009 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003010 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3011
3012 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3013 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003014
3015 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003016 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003017 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3018 // call, and continue on.
3019 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3020 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3021 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3022 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3023 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3025 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003026 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3027 ->isRecordType()))) {
3028 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3029 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3030 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003031 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003032
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003033 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003034 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003035 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003036 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003038
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003039 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3040 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3041 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3042 }
3043 }
3044 }
3045
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003046 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3047 // use that.
3048 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003049 if (IsArrow) {
3050 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3051 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3052 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003053 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003054 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003055 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3056 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003057 }
3058 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003059 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3060 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3061 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3062 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003063 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003064 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003065 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003067 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3068 // use that.
3069 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3070 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3071 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3072 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3073 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003074 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003075 }
3076 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003077
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003078 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003079
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003081 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003082 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3083 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3084 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3085 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3086 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3087 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3088 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3089 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3090 // Check the use of this method.
3091 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3092 return ExprError();
3093 }
3094 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3095 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3096 Selector SetterSel =
3097 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3098 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3099 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3100 if (!Setter) {
3101 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3102 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003103 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003104 }
3105 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3106 if (!Setter)
3107 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003108
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003109 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3110 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003111
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 if (Getter || Setter) {
3113 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003114
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003116 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 else
3118 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3119 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3120 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003121 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003122 PType,
3123 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3124 }
3125 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3126 << MemberName << BaseType);
3127 }
3128 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003129
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3131 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3132 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003133 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003134 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003135
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003136 if (IsArrow) {
3137 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003138 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003139 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3140 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003141 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3142 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3143 // struct MyRecord foo;
3144 // foo->bar
3145 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3146 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3147 // by now.
3148 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3149 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003150 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003151 IsArrow = false;
3152 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003153 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3154 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3155 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003156 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003157 } else {
3158 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3159 // type *foo;
3160 // foo.bar
3161 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3162 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3163 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3164 // the appropriate pointer type
3165 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3166 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3167 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3168 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3169 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003170 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003171 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3172 IsArrow = true;
3173 }
3174 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003175 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003176
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003177 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003178 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003179 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003180 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003181 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003182 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003183 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003184
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003185 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3186 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003187 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003188 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003189 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003190 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3191 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3192 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3193 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3195
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003196 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003197 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003198
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003199 if (!IV) {
3200 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3201 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3202 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003203 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003204 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003205 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003206 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3207 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003208 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3209 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003210 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003211 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003212 } else {
3213 Res.clear();
3214 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003215 }
3216 }
3217
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 if (IV) {
3219 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3220 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3221 // error cases.
3222 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003224
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3226 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3227 return ExprError();
3228 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3229 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3230 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3231 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3232 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3233 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3234 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3235 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3236 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3237 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3238 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3239 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003241 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003242 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3243 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003244 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3246 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003247
3248 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3249 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003251 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003253 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3254 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003255 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003257 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258
3259 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3260 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003261 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003262 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003263 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003264 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003265 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003266 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003267 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003268 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3270 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003271 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003274 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003276 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3277 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003278 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3279 // Check the use of this declaration
3280 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3281 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003282
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003283 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3284 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3285 }
3286 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3287 // Check the use of this method.
3288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3289 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003290 Selector SetterSel =
3291 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3292 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3293 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3294 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3295 SetterSel, Context))
3296 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3297 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3298 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3299 SMD,
3300 MemberLoc,
3301 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003302 }
3303 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003304
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003305 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003306 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003307 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003308
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003309 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3310 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003311 if (!IsArrow)
3312 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3313 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003314 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003315
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003316 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003317 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003318 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3319 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003320 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003321 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003322 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003323
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003324 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003325 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003326 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003327 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3328 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003329 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003330 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003331 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003332 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003333
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003334 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3335 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3336
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003337 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003338}
3339
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3341/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3342/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3343/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3344/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3345///
3346/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3347/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3348/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3349/// only be called
3350/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3351/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3352/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003353ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003354 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3355 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003356 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003357 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003358 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3360 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3361 return ExprError();
3362
3363 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3364
3365 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003366 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3368 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003369 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003371 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003372 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3373
3374 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3375 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3376 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3377
3378 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003379 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003380 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3381 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003382
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003383 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3384 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003385 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003386 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3387 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003388 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003389 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003390 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003391 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3392 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003393
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003394 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3395 Owned(Base);
3396 return ExprError();
3397 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003399 if (Result.get()) {
3400 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3401 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3402 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3403 // call now.
3404 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3405 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003406 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003407
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003408 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003409 }
3410
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003411 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003412 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3413 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003414 }
3415
3416 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003417}
3418
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003419ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003420 FunctionDecl *FD,
3421 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3422 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003423 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003424 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3425 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003426 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003427 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003428 return ExprError();
3429 }
3430
3431 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3432 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003433
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003434 // Instantiate the expression.
3435 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3436 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003437
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003438 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3439 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3440 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3441 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003442
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003443 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3444 if (Result.isInvalid())
3445 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003446
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003447 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3448 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003449 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003450 InitializationKind Kind
3451 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3452 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3453 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003454
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003455 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3456 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3457 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3458 if (Result.isInvalid())
3459 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003460
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003461 // Build the default argument expression.
3462 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3463 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003464 }
3465
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003466 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3467 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3468 // be properly destroyed.
3469 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3470 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003471 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3472 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3473 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3474 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3475 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3476 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003477
3478 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003479 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3480 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003481 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003482 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003483}
3484
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003485/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3486/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3487/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3488/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3489/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3490/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003491bool
3492Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003494 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3496 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003497 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003498 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3499 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003500 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003501
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003502 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3503 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3504 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3505 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3506 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003507 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003508 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003509 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003510 }
3511
3512 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3513 // them.
3514 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3515 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3516 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3517 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003518 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003519 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003520 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3521 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3522 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003523 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003524 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003525 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003526 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003527 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003528 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003529 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3530 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3531 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3532 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3533 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003534 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003535 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003536 if (Invalid)
3537 return true;
3538 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3539 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3540 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003541
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003542 return false;
3543}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003544
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003545bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3546 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3547 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3548 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3549 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3550 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003551 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003552 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3553 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3554 bool Invalid = false;
3555 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3556 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3557 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3558 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003560 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003561 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003562
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003563 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003564 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3565 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003566
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003567 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3568 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003569 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003570 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003571 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003572
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003573 // Pass the argument
3574 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3575 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3576 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003577
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003578 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003579 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3580 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003581 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003582 SourceLocation(),
3583 Owned(Arg));
3584 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3585 return true;
3586
3587 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003588 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003589 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003590
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003591 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003592 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003593 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3594 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003596 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003597 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003598 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003599 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003600
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003601 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003602 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003603 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003604 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003605 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003606 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003607 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003608 }
3609 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003610 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003611}
3612
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003613/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003614/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3615/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003616ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003617Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003618 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003619 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003620
3621 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003622 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003623 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3624 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003625
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003626 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003627
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003628 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003629 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3630 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3631 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3632 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3633 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003634 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003635 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3636 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003637
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003638 NumArgs = 0;
3639 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003640
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003641 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3642 RParenLoc));
3643 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003644
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003645 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003646 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003647 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3648 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003649 bool Dependent = false;
3650 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3651 Dependent = true;
3652 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3653 Dependent = true;
3654
3655 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003656 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003657 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3658
3659 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3660 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3661 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003662 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003663
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003664 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3665
3666 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3667 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3668 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3669 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3670 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3671 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3672 // method template.
3673 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003674 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3675 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003676 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003677
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003678 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003679 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003680 }
3681
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003682 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003683 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003684 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003685 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003686 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003687 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003688 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003689
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003690 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003691 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003692 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3693 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003694 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3695 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003696 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003697
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003698 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3699 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3700 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3701 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003702
3703 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3704 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003705 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003706 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003707
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003708 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003709 RParenLoc))
3710 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003711
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003712 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003713 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003714 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003715 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3716 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003717 }
3718 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003719 }
3720
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003721 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003722 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003723 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003724
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003725 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003726 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3727 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003728 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003729 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003730 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003731
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003732 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3733 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3734 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3735
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003736 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3737}
3738
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003739/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3740/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003741/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3742/// block-pointer type.
3743///
3744/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003745ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003746Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3747 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3748 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3749 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3750 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3751
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003752 // Promote the function operand.
3753 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3754
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003755 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3756 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003757 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3758 Args, NumArgs,
3759 Context.BoolTy,
3760 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003761
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003762 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3763 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3764 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3765 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003766 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003767 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003768 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3769 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003770 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003771 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003772 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003773 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003774 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003775 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003776 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3777 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3778
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003779 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003780 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003781 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003782 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003783 return ExprError();
3784
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003785 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003786 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003787
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003788 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003789 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003790 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003791 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003792 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003793 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003794
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003795 if (FDecl) {
3796 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3797 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3798 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003799 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003800 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003801 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003802 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3803 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3804 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3805 }
3806 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003807 }
3808
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003809 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003810 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3811 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3812 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003813 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3814 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003815 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3816 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003817 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003818 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003819 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003820 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003821
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003822 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3823 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003824 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3825 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003826
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003827 // Check for sentinels
3828 if (NDecl)
3829 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003830
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003831 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003832 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003833 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003834 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003835
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003836 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003837 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003838 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003839 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003840 return ExprError();
3841 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003842
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003843 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003844}
3845
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003846ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003847Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003848 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003849 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003850 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003851 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003852
3853 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3854 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3855 if (!TInfo)
3856 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3857
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003858 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003859}
3860
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003861ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003862Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003863 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003864 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003865
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003866 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003867 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003868 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3869 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003870 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3871 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003872 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003873 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003874 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003875 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003876
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003877 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003878 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003879 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003880 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003881 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003882 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003883 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003884 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003885 &literalType);
3886 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003887 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003888 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003889
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003890 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003891 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003892 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003893 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003894 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003895
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003896 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003897 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003898}
3899
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003900ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003901Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003902 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3903 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003904 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003905
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003906 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003907 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003908
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003909 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3910 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003911 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003912 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003913}
3914
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003915static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003916 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003917 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003918 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003919
3920 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3921 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003922 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003923 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3924 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003928
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003929 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3930 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003931 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003932 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003933 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003934 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003935 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003936 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003937
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003938 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3939 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003940 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003941 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003942 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003943 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003944
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003945 // FIXME: Assert here.
3946 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003947 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003948}
3949
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003950/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003951bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003952 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003953 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003954 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003955 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003956 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3957 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003958
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003959 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003960
3961 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3962 // type needs to be scalar.
3963 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3964 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003965 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003966 return false;
3967 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003968
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003969 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3970 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3971 return true;
3972
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003973 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003974 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003975 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3976 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003977 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003978 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3979 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003980 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003981 return false;
3982 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003983
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003984 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003985 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003986 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003987 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003988 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003989 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003990 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00003991 castExpr->getType()) &&
3992 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003993 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3994 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3995 break;
3996 }
3997 }
3998 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3999 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4000 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004001 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004002 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004003 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004004
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004005 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4006 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4007 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4008 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004009
4010 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004011 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004012 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4013 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004014 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004015 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
4017 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004018 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004019
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004020 if (castType->isVectorType())
4021 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4022 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4023 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4024
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004025 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4026 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004027
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004028 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004029 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004030 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004031 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004032 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4033 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4034 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4035 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004036 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004037 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4038 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4039 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004040 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004041
4042 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004043
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004044 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004045 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4046
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004047 return false;
4048}
4049
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004050bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004051 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004052 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004053
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004054 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004055 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004056 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004057 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004058 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004059 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004060 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004061 } else
4062 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004063 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004064 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004065
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004066 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004067 return false;
4068}
4069
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004070bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004071 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004072 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004073
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004074 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004075
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004076 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4077 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004078 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4079 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4080 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4081 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004082 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004083 return false;
4084 }
4085
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004086 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004087 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4088 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004089 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4090 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4091 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4092 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004093
4094 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4095 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4096 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004097
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004098 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004099 return false;
4100}
4101
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004102ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004103Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004104 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4105 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004106 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004107
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004108 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4109 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4110 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004111 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004112
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4114 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004115 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004116 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004117
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004118 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004119}
4120
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004121ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004122Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004123 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004124 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004125 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004126 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004127 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004128 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004129
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004130 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004131 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004132 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4133 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004134}
4135
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004136/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4137/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004138ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004139Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004140 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4141 if (!E)
4142 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004143
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004144 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004145
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004147 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4148 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004149
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004150 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4151
4152 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004153}
4154
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004155ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004156Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004157 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004158 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004159 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004160 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004161 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004162
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004163 // Check for an altivec literal,
4164 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004165 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4166 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4167 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4168 return ExprError();
4169 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004170 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4171 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4172 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4173 }
4174 else
4175 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4176 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004177
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004178 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4179 // then handle it as such.
4180 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004181 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4182 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4183 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4184
4185 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4186 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004187 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4188 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4190 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004191 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004192 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004193 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004194 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004195 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004196 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4197 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004198 }
4199}
4200
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004201ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004202 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004203 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004204 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004205 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4206 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004207 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4208 Expr *expr;
4209 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4210 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4211 else
4212 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004213 return Owned(expr);
4214}
4215
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004216/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4217/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004218/// C99 6.5.15
4219QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004220 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004221 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004222 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4223 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004224 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004225
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004226 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004227 if (SAVE) {
4228 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4229 }
4230 else
4231 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004232 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4233 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4234 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4235 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004236
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004237 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004238 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004239 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4240 // Throw an error if its not either.
4241 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4242 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4243 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4244 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4245 << CondTy;
4246 return QualType();
4247 }
4248 }
4249 else {
4250 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4251 << CondTy;
4252 return QualType();
4253 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004254 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004255
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004256 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004257 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4258 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004259
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004260 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4261 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4262 // built in select.
4263 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4264 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4265 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4266 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4267 << CondTy;
4268 return QualType();
4269 }
4270 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4271 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4272 << CondTy;
4273 return QualType();
4274 }
4275 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4276 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4277 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4278 }
4279
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004280 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4281 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004282 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4283 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4284 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004285 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004286
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004287 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4288 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004289 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4290 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004291 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004292 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004293 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004294 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004295 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004296 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004297
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004298 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004299 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004300 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4301 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4302 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4303 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4304 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4305 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4306 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004307 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4308 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004309 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004310 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004311 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4312 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004313 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004314 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004315 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004316 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004317 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004318 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004319 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004320 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004321 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004322 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004323 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004324
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004325 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4326 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4327 QuestionLoc);
4328 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4329 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004330
4331
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 // Handle block pointer types.
4333 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4334 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4335 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4336 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004337 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4338 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 return destType;
4340 }
4341 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004342 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004343 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004344 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4346 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4347 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004348 return LHSTy;
4349 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004350 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004351 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4352 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004353
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004354 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4355 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004356 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004357 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004358 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4359 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4360 // to get a consistent AST.
4361 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004362 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004364 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004365 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004366 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004367 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4368 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004369 return LHSTy;
4370 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004371
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004372 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4373 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4374 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004375 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4376 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004377
4378 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4379 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4380 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004381 QualType destPointee
4382 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004383 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004384 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004385 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004386 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004388 return destType;
4389 }
4390 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004391 QualType destPointee
4392 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004393 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004394 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004395 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004396 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004397 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004398 return destType;
4399 }
4400
4401 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4402 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4403 return LHSTy;
4404 }
4405 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4406 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4407 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4408 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4409 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4410 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4411 // to get a consistent AST.
4412 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004413 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4414 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004415 return incompatTy;
4416 }
4417 // The pointer types are compatible.
4418 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4419 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4420 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4421 // type.
4422 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4423 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004424 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4425 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004426 return LHSTy;
4427 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004428
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004429 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4430 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4431 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4432 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004433 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004434 return RHSTy;
4435 }
4436 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4437 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4438 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004439 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004440 return LHSTy;
4441 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004442
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004443 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004444 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4445 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004446 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004447}
4448
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004449/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4450/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4451QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4452 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4453 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4454 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004455
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004456 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4457 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4458 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4459 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4460 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004461 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004462 return LHSTy;
4463 }
4464 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4465 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004466 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004467 return RHSTy;
4468 }
4469 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4470 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4471 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004472 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004473 return LHSTy;
4474 }
4475 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4476 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004477 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004478 return RHSTy;
4479 }
4480 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4481 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4482 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004483 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004484 return LHSTy;
4485 }
4486 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4487 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004488 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004489 return RHSTy;
4490 }
4491 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4492 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004493
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004494 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4495 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4496 return LHSTy;
4497 }
4498 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4499 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4500 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004502 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4503 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4504 // type. This allows
4505 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4506 // where B is a subclass of A.
4507 //
4508 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4509 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4510 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4511 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004512
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004513 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4514 // It could return the composite type.
4515 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4516 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4517 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4518 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4519 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4520 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4521 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4522 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4523 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4524 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4525 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4526 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4527 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4528 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004529 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004530 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4531 ;
4532 else {
4533 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4534 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4535 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4536 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004537 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4538 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004539 return incompatTy;
4540 }
4541 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004542 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4543 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004544 return compositeType;
4545 }
4546 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4547 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4548 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4549 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4550 QualType destPointee
4551 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4552 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4553 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004554 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004555 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004556 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004557 return destType;
4558 }
4559 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4560 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4561 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4562 QualType destPointee
4563 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4564 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4565 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004566 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004567 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004568 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004569 return destType;
4570 }
4571 return QualType();
4572}
4573
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004574/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004575/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004576ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004577 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004578 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4579 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004580 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4581 // was the condition.
4582 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004583 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4584 if (isLHSNull) {
4585 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4586 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004587
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004588 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4589 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004590 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004591 return ExprError();
4592
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004593 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004594 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4595 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4596 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004597}
4598
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004599// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004600// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004601// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4602// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4603// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004604Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004605Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004606 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004607
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004608 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4609 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4610 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4611 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4612 return Compatible;
4613 }
4614
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004615 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004616 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4617 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004618
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004619 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004620 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4621 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004622
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004623 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
4625 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4626 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4627 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004628 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004629 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004630 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004631
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4633 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004634 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004635 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004636 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004637 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004639 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004640 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4641 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004642 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004643
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004644 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004645 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004646 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004647
4648 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004649 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4650 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004651 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004652 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004653 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004654 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4655 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4656 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4657 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4658 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4659 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004660 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004661 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004662 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004663 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004664
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004665 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004666 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004667 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004668 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004669
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004670 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4671 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4672 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4673 // warning can be disabled.
4674 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4675 return ConvTy;
4676 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4677 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004678
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004679 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4680 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4681 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4682 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4683 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4684 do {
4685 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4686 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004687
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004688 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4689 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4690 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004691
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004692 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004693 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004694 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004695
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004696 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004697 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004698 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004699 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004700}
4701
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004702/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4703/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4704/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4705// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004706Sema::AssignConvertType
4707Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004708 QualType rhsType) {
4709 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004710
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004711 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004712 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4713 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004715 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4716 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4717 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004718
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004719 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004720
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004721 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004722 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004723 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004724
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004725 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4726 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4727 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4728 }
4729 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004730 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004731 return ConvTy;
4732}
4733
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004734/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4735/// for assignment compatibility.
4736Sema::AssignConvertType
4737Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004738 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4739 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004740 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4741 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004742 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004743 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004744 }
4745 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4746 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004747 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4748 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004749 return IncompatiblePointer;
4750 return Compatible;
4751 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004752 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004753 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004754 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004755 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4756 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4757 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4758 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4759 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4760 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004761
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004762 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4763 return Compatible;
4764 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4765 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004766 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004767}
4768
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004769/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4770/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004771/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4772///
4773/// int a, *pint;
4774/// short *pshort;
4775/// struct foo *pfoo;
4776///
4777/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4778/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4779/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4780/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4781///
4782/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004783/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004784///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004785Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004786Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004787 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4788 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004789 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4790 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004791
4792 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004793 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004794
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004795 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4796 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4797 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4798 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4799 return Compatible;
4800 }
4801
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004802 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4803 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4804 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4805 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4806 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4807 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4808 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004809 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004810 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004811 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004812 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004813 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004814 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4815 // to the same ExtVector type.
4816 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4817 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4818 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004819 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004820 return Compatible;
4821 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004822
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004823 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004824 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4825 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4826 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4827 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4828 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4829 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004830 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004831
4832 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4833 // vector type and vice versa
4834 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4835 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004836 }
4837 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004838 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004839
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004840 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4841 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004842 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004843
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004844 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004845 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004846 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004847
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004848 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004849 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004850
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004851 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004852 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004853 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4854 return Compatible;
4855 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004856 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004857 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4858 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004859 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004860
4861 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004862 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004863 return Compatible;
4864 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004865 return Incompatible;
4866 }
4867
4868 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4869 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004870 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004871
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004872 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004873 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004874 return Compatible;
4875
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004876 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4877 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004878
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004879 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004880 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004881 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004882 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004883 return Incompatible;
4884 }
4885
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004886 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4887 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4888 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004889
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004890 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004891 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004892 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4893 return Compatible;
4894 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004895 }
4896 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004897 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004898 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004899 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004900 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4901 return Compatible;
4902 }
4903 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4904 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4905 return Compatible;
4906 return Incompatible;
4907 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004908 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004909 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004910 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4911 return Compatible;
4912
4913 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004914 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004915
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004916 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004917 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004918
4919 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004920 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004921 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004922 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004923 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004924 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4925 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4926 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4927 return Compatible;
4928
4929 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4930 return PointerToInt;
4931
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004932 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004933 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004934 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4935 return Compatible;
4936 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004937 }
4938 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004939 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004940 return Compatible;
4941 return Incompatible;
4942 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004943
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004944 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004945 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004946 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004947 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004948 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004949}
4950
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004951/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4952/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004953static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004954 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4955 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4956 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004957 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004958 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004959 SourceLocation());
4960 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4961 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4962
4963 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4964 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004965 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004966 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004967 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004968}
4969
4970Sema::AssignConvertType
4971Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4972 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4973
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004974 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004975 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4976 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004977 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004978 return Incompatible;
4979
4980 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4981 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4982 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4983 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004984 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4985 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004986 it != itend; ++it) {
4987 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4988 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4989 // 1) void pointer
4990 // 2) null pointer constant
4991 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004992 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004993 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004994 InitField = *it;
4995 break;
4996 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004997
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004999 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005000 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005001 InitField = *it;
5002 break;
5003 }
5004 }
5005
5006 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5007 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005008 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005009 InitField = *it;
5010 break;
5011 }
5012 }
5013
5014 if (!InitField)
5015 return Incompatible;
5016
5017 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5018 return Compatible;
5019}
5020
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005021Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005022Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005023 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5024 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5025 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5026 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5027 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005028 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005029 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005030 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005031 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005032 }
5033
5034 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5035 // structures.
5036 }
5037
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005038 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5039 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005040 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5041 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005042 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005043 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005044 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005045 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005046 return Compatible;
5047 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005048
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005049 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005050 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005051 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005052 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005053 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005054 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005055 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005056 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005057
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005058 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5059 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005060
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005061 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5062 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005063 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5064 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5065 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5066 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005067 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005068 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005069 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005070 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005071}
5072
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005073QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005074 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005075 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005076 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005077 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005078}
5079
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005080QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005081 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005082 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005083 QualType lhsType =
5084 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5085 QualType rhsType =
5086 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005087
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005088 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005089 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005090 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005091
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005092 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5093 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005094 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005095 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005096 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005097 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005098 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005099 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005100 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005101 return lhsType;
5102 }
5103
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005104 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005105 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005106 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5107 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5108 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5109 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5110 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5111 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005112 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005113 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005114 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005115 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005116
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005117 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5118 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5119 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005120 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005121 return rhsType;
5122 }
5123
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005124 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5125 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5126 bool swapped = false;
5127 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5128 swapped = true;
5129 std::swap(rex, lex);
5130 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5131 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005132
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005133 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005134 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005135 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005136 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005137 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005138 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005139 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5140 return lhsType;
5141 }
5142 }
5143 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5144 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5145 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005146 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005147 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5148 return lhsType;
5149 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005150 }
5151 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005153 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005154 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005155 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005156 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005157 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005158}
5159
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005160QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5161 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005162 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005163 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005164
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005165 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005167 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5168 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5169 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005170
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005171 // Check for division by zero.
5172 if (isDiv &&
5173 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005174 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005175 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005176
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005177 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005178}
5179
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005180QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005181 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005182 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005183 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5184 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005185 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5186 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5187 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005188
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005189 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005190
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005191 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5192 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005193
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005194 // Check for remainder by zero.
5195 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005196 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5197 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005198
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005199 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005200}
5201
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005202QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005203 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005204 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5205 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5206 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5207 return compType;
5208 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005209
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005210 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005211
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005212 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005213 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5214 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5215 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005216 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005217 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005218
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005219 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5220 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005221 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005222 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5223
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005224 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005225
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005226 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005227 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005228
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005229 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5230 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005231 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5232 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005233 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005234 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005235 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005236
5237 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5238 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5239 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005240 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005241 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5242 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5243 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5244 return QualType();
5245 }
5246
5247 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5248 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5249 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005250 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005251 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005252 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005253 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005254 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5255 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005256 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5257 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005258 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005259 return QualType();
5260 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005261 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005262 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005263 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5264 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5265 return QualType();
5266 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005267
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005268 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005269 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5270 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5271 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5272 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5273 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005274 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005275 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5276 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005277 return PExp->getType();
5278 }
5279 }
5280
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005281 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005282}
5283
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005284// C99 6.5.6
5285QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005286 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5287 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5288 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5289 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5290 return compType;
5291 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005292
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005293 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005294
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005295 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005296
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005297 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005298 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5299 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005300 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005301 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005302 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005303
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005304 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005305 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005306 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005307
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005308 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005309
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5311 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5312 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5313 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5314 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5315 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5316 return QualType();
5317 }
5318
5319 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5320 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5321 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5322 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5323 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005324 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005325 return QualType();
5326 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005327
5328 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5329 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5330 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005331 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005332 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005333 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005334 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005335 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005336
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005337 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005338 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005339 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5340 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5341 return QualType();
5342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005343
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005344 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005345 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5346 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5348 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5349 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5350 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005351 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005352 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5353
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005354 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005355 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005356 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005357
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005358 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005359 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005360 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005361
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005362 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5363 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5364 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5365 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5366 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5367 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5368 return QualType();
5369 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005370
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005371 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5372 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5373 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5374 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005375 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005376 return QualType();
5377 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005378
5379 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5380 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5381 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5382 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5383 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005384 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5385 << rex->getSourceRange()
5386 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005387 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005388
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005389 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5390 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5391 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5392 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5393 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5394 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5395 return QualType();
5396 }
5397 } else {
5398 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5399 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5400 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5401 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5402 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5403 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5404 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5405 return QualType();
5406 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005407 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005408
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005409 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5410 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5411 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5412 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5413 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005414 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005415 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005416
5417 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005418 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5419 }
5420 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005421
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005422 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005423}
5424
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005425static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5426 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5427 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5428 return false;
5429}
5430
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005431// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005432QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005433 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005434 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005435 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5436 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005437 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005438
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005439 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5440 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5441 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5442 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5443 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5444 }
5445
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005446 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5447 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5448 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5449
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005450 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5451 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005452 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5453 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5454 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5455 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5456 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005457 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005458 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005459 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005460
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005461 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005462
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005463 // Sanity-check shift operands
5464 llvm::APSInt Right;
5465 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005466 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5467 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005468 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005469 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5470 else {
5471 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5472 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5473 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5474 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5475 }
5476 }
5477
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005478 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005479 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005480}
5481
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005482static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5483 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5484 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5485 return true;
5486 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5487 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5488 }
5489 return false;
5490}
5491
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005492// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005493QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005494 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005495 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005496
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005497 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005498 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005499 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005500
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005501 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5502 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005503
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005504 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005505 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5506 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5507 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005508 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5509 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5510 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005511 //
5512 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5513 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5514 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5515 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5516 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5517 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005518 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5519 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005520 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005521 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005522 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005523 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005524 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5525 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005526 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5527 || Opc == BO_LE
5528 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005529 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5530 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5531 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5532 // what is it always going to eval to?
5533 char always_evals_to;
5534 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005535 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005536 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5537 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005538 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005539 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5540 break;
5541 default:
5542 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5543 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5544 break;
5545 }
5546 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5547 << 1 // array
5548 << always_evals_to);
5549 }
5550 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005551 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005553 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5554 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5555 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5556 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005557
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005558 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5559 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005560 Expr *literalString = 0;
5561 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005562 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005563 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005564 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005565 literalString = lex;
5566 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005567 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5568 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005569 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005570 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005571 literalString = rex;
5572 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5573 }
5574
5575 if (literalString) {
5576 std::string resultComparison;
5577 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005578 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5579 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5580 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5581 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5582 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5583 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005584 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5585 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005586
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005587 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5588 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5589 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005590 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005591 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005592 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005593
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005594 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5595 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5596 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5597 else {
5598 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5599 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5600 }
5601
5602 lType = lex->getType();
5603 rType = rex->getType();
5604
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005606 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005607
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005608 if (isRelational) {
5609 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005610 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005611 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005612 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005613 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005614 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005615
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005616 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005617 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005618 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005620 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005621 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005622 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005623 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005625 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5626 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005627 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005628 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005629 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005630 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005631 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005632
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005633 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005634 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5635 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005636 if (!isRelational &&
5637 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5638 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5639 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005640 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5641 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005642 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5643 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005644 Diag(Loc,
5645 isSFINAEContext()?
5646 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5647 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005648 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005649
5650 if (isSFINAEContext())
5651 return QualType();
5652
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005653 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005654 return ResultTy;
5655 }
5656 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005657 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5658 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5659 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5660 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5661 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5662 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005663 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005664 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005665 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005666 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005667 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005668 if (T.isNull()) {
5669 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5670 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5671 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005672 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005673 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005674 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005675 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005676 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005677 }
5678
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005679 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5680 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005681 return ResultTy;
5682 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005683 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5684 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5685 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5686 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5687 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5688 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5689 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5690 }
5691 } else if (!isRelational &&
5692 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5693 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5694 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5695 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5696 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5697 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5698 }
5699 } else {
5700 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005701 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005702 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005703 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005704 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005705 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005706 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005707 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005708
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005709 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005710 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005711 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005713 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5714 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005715 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5716 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005717 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5718 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005719 return ResultTy;
5720 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005721 if (LHSIsNull &&
5722 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5723 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005724 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5725 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005726 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5727 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005728 return ResultTy;
5729 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005730
5731 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005732 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005733 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5734 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005735 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5736 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5737 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5738 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5739 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5740 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5741 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5742 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005743 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005744 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005745 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005746 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005747 if (T.isNull()) {
5748 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005749 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005750 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005751 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005752 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005753 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005754 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005755 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005756 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005757
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005758 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5759 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005760 return ResultTy;
5761 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005762
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005763 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005764 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5765 return ResultTy;
5766 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005767
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005768 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005769 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005770 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5771 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005772
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005773 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005774 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005775 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005776 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005777 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005778 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005779 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005780 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005781 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005782 if (!isRelational
5783 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5784 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005785 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005786 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005787 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005788 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005789 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5790 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5791 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005792 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005793 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005794 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005795 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005796
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005797 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005798 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005799 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5800 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005801 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005802 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005803 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005804 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005805
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005806 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5807 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005808 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005809 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005810 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005811 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005812 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005813 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005814 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005815 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005816 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5817 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005818 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005819 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005820 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005821 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005822 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5823 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005824 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005825 bool isError = false;
5826 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5827 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5828 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005829 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005830 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005831 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005832 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5833 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5834 isError = true;
5835 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005836 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005837
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005838 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005839 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005840 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005841 if (isError)
5842 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005843 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005844
5845 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005846 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005847 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005848 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005849 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005850 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005851
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005852 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005853 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5854 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005855 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005856 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005857 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005858 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5859 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005860 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005861 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005862 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005863 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005864}
5865
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005866/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005867/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005868/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5869/// types.
5870QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005871 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005872 bool isRelational) {
5873 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5874 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005875 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005876 if (vType.isNull())
5877 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005878
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005879 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5880 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005881
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005882 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5883 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5884 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005885 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005886 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5887 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5888 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005889 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5890 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5891 << 0 // self-
5892 << 2 // "a constant"
5893 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005894 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005895
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005896 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005897 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5898 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005899 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005900 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005901
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005902 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5903 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5904 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005905 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005906 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005907
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005908 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005909 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005910 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005911 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005912 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005913 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5914
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005915 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005916 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005917 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5918}
5919
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005920inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005921 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005922 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5923 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5924 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5925 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5926
5927 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5928 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005929
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005930 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005931
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005932 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5933 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005934 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005935 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005936}
5937
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005938inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005939 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5940
5941 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5942 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5943 // is a constant.
5944 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005945 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005946 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005947 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5948 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5949 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5950 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5951 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5952 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5953 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5954 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5955 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005956 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5957 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005958 }
5959 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005960
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005961 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5962 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5963 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005964
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005965 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5966 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005967
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005968 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005970
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005971 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5972 // non-overloadable operands.
5973
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005974 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5975 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005976 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5977 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5978 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005979 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005980
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005981 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5982 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5983 // The result is a bool.
5984 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005985}
5986
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005987/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5988/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5989/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5990///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005991static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005992 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5993 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5994 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5995 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005996 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005997 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5998 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5999 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6000 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006001 }
6002 }
6003 return false;
6004}
6005
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006006/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6007/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6008static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006009 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006010 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006011 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006012 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6013 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006014 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6015 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006016
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006017 unsigned Diag = 0;
6018 bool NeedType = false;
6019 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006020 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006021 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006022 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6023 NeedType = true;
6024 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006025 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006026 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6027 NeedType = true;
6028 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006029 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006030 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6031 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006032 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6033 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006034 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006035 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6036 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006037 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6038 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006039 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6040 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006041 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006042 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006043 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006044 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006045 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6046 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006047 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006048 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6049 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006050 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6051 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6052 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006053 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6054 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6055 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006056 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6057 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6058 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006059 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006060
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006061 SourceRange Assign;
6062 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6063 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006064 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006065 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006066 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006067 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006068 return true;
6069}
6070
6071
6072
6073// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006074QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6075 SourceLocation Loc,
6076 QualType CompoundType) {
6077 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6078 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006079 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006080
6081 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6082 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006083 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006084 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006085 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006086 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006087 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006088 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006089 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6090 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6091 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006092 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006093 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006094 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006095 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006096
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006097 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6098 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6099 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006100 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006101 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6102 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6103 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006104 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6105 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006106 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006107 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006108 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6109 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6110 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006111 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6112 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006113 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006114 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006115 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006116 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006117 }
6118 } else {
6119 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006120 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006121 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006122
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006123 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006124 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006125 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006126
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006127
6128 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6129 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6130 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6131 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6132 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6133 // check.
6134 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006135 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006136 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6137 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6138 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6139 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6140 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6141 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6142 }
6143
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006144 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6145 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006146 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006147 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6148 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006149 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006150 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006151 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006152}
6153
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006154// C99 6.5.17
6155QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006156 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6157
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006158 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006159 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6160 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6161 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006162
6163 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6164 // incomplete in C++).
6165
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006166 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006167}
6168
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006169/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6170/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006171QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006172 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006173 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6174 return Context.DependentTy;
6175
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006176 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6177 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006178
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6180 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6181 if (!isInc) {
6182 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6183 return QualType();
6184 }
6185 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6186 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6187 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006188 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006189 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6190 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006191
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006192 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006193 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006194 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6195 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6196 << Op->getSourceRange();
6197 return QualType();
6198 }
6199
6200 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006201 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006202 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006203 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6205 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6206 return QualType();
6207 }
6208
6209 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006210 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006211 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006212 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006213 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006214 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006215 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006216 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006217 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6219 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6220 return QualType();
6221 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006222 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006223 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006225 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006226 } else {
6227 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006228 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006229 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006230 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006231 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006232 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006233 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006234 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006235 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6236 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6237 // operand.
6238 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6239 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006240}
6241
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006242void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6243 bool copyInit = false;
6244 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6245 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6246 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6247 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6248 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6249 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6250 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6251 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6252 }
6253 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6254 }
6255 else
6256 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6257 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6258 if (copyInit) {
6259 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006260 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006261 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6262 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6263 Owned(Arg));
6264 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006265 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006266 }
6267}
6268
6269
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006270/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006271/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006272/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6273/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6274/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6275/// - &(x) => x
6276/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6277/// - &s.xx => s
6278/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6279/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6280/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6281/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006282static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006283 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006284 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006285 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006286 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006287 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6288 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6289 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006290 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006291 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006292 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006293 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006294 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006295 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6296 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006297 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6298 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6299 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6300 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6301 }
6302 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006303 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006304 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6305 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006306
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006307 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006308 case UO_Real:
6309 case UO_Imag:
6310 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006311 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6312 default:
6313 return 0;
6314 }
6315 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006316 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006317 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006318 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006319 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6320 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006321 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006322 default:
6323 return 0;
6324 }
6325}
6326
6327/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006328/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006329/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006330/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006331/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006332/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006333/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006334QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6335 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006336 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006337 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6338 return Context.OverloadTy;
6339
6340 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6341 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006342
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006343 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6344 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6345 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006346 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006347 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6348 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6349 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6350 }
6351 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6352 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6353 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006354 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006355 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006356
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006357 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006358 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6359 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6360 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6361 if (isSFINAEContext())
6362 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006363 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006364 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006365 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6366 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6367 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6368
6369 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6370 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6371 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6372 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6373 return QualType();
6374 }
6375 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6376 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6377
6378 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6379 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6380 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6381 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6382
6383 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6384 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6385 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6386 << op->getSourceRange();
6387 }
6388
6389 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6390 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6391 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006392 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006393 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006394 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006395 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006396 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6397 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006398 return QualType();
6399 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006400 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006401 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6402 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6403 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006404 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006405 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006406 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006407 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006408 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006409 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006410 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6411 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6412 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6413 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6414 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006415 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6416 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006417 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6418 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006419 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006420 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006421 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6422 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006423 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6424 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006425 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006426 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006427 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6428 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006429 return QualType();
6430 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006431 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006432 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006433 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006434 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006435 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6436 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006437 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006438 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006439 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6440 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006441 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006442 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6443 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6444 return QualType();
6445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006446
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006447 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6448 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006449 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006450 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006451 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006452 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006453 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006454
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006455 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6456 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6457 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6458 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6459 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6460 }
6461
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006462 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006463 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6464 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006465 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006466}
6467
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006468/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006469QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006470 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6471 return Context.DependentTy;
6472
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006473 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006474 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6475 QualType Result;
6476
6477 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6478 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6479 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6480 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6481 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6482 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6483 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6484 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6485 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006486
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006487 if (Result.isNull()) {
6488 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6489 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6490 return QualType();
6491 }
6492
6493 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006494}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006495
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006496static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006497 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006498 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006499 switch (Kind) {
6500 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006501 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6502 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6503 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6504 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6505 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6506 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6507 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6508 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6509 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6510 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6511 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6512 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6513 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6514 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6515 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6516 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6517 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6518 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6519 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6520 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6521 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6522 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6523 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6524 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6525 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6526 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6527 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6528 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6529 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6530 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6531 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6532 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006533 }
6534 return Opc;
6535}
6536
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006537static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006538 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006539 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006540 switch (Kind) {
6541 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006542 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6543 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6544 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6545 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6546 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6547 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6548 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6549 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6550 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6551 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6552 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006553 }
6554 return Opc;
6555}
6556
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006557/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6558/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6559/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006560ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006561 unsigned Op,
6562 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006563 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006565 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6566 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6567 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006568
6569 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006570 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006571 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6572 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006573 case BO_PtrMemD:
6574 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006575 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006576 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006577 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006578 case BO_Mul:
6579 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006580 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006581 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006582 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006583 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006584 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6585 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006586 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006587 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6588 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006589 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006590 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6591 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006592 case BO_Shl:
6593 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006594 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6595 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006596 case BO_LE:
6597 case BO_LT:
6598 case BO_GE:
6599 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006600 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006601 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006602 case BO_EQ:
6603 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006604 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006605 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006606 case BO_And:
6607 case BO_Xor:
6608 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006609 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6610 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006611 case BO_LAnd:
6612 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006613 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006614 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006615 case BO_MulAssign:
6616 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006617 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006618 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006619 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6620 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6621 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006622 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006623 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006624 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6625 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6626 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6627 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006629 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006630 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6631 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6632 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006633 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006634 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006635 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6636 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6637 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006638 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006639 case BO_ShlAssign:
6640 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006641 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6642 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6643 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6644 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006645 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006646 case BO_AndAssign:
6647 case BO_XorAssign:
6648 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006649 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6650 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6651 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6652 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006653 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006654 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006655 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6656 break;
6657 }
6658 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006659 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006660 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006661 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006662 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6663 << ResultTy;
6664 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006665 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006666 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6667 else
6668 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006669 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6670 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006671}
6672
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006673/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6674/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006675static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6676 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006677 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6678 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6679 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006680 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006681 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6682
6683 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6684 return;
6685
6686 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6687 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6688 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006689 return;
6690 }
6691
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006692 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6693 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006694 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006695
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006696 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006697 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006698
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006699 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6700 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6701 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6702 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006703 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006704 return;
6705 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006706
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006707 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006708 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6709 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006710}
6711
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006712/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6713/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6714/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6715/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006717 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006718 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6719 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6720 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6721 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006722 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006723 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006724 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6725
6726 // Subs are not binary operators.
6727 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6728 return;
6729
6730 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6731 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006732 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6733 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006734 return;
6735
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006736 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006737 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006738 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006739 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6740 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006741 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006742 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006743 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6744 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6745 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6746 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006747 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006748 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006749 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006750 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6751 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006752 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006753 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006754 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6755 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6756 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6757 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006758}
6759
6760/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6761/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6762/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006763static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006764 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006765 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006766 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6767}
6768
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006769// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006770ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006771 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6772 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6773 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006774 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6775 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006776
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006777 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6778 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6779
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006780 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6781}
6782
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006783ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006784 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6785 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006786 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006787 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6788 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006789 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006790 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006791 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6792 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6793 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6794 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6795 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006796 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006797 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006798 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6799 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6800 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006801
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006802 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6803 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006804 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006805 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006806
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006807 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006808 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006809}
6810
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006811ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006812 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006813 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006814 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006815
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006816 QualType resultType;
6817 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006818 case UO_PreInc:
6819 case UO_PreDec:
6820 case UO_PostInc:
6821 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006822 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006823 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6824 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6825 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6826 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006827 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006828 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006829 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006830 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006831 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006832 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006833 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006834 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006835 case UO_Plus:
6836 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006837 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6838 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006839 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6840 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006841 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6842 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006843 break;
6844 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6845 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6846 break;
6847 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006848 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006849 resultType->isPointerType())
6850 break;
6851
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006852 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6853 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006854 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006855 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6856 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006857 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6858 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006859 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6860 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6861 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006862 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006863 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006864 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006865 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6866 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006867 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006868 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006869 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006870 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006871 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006872 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6873 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006874 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006875 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6876 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006877
6878 // Do not accept &f if f is overloaded
6879 // i.e. void f(int); void f(char); bool b = &f;
6880 if (resultType == Context.OverloadTy &&
6881 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Input))
6882 return ExprError(); // Diagnostic is uttered above
6883
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006884 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006885 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6886 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006887 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006888 case UO_Real:
6889 case UO_Imag:
6890 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006891 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006892 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006893 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006894 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006895 }
6896 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006897 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006898
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006899 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006900}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006901
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006902ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006903 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6904 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006905 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006906 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006907 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6908 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6909 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6910 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006911 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006912 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006913 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6914 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6915 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006916
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006917 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006918 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006919
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006920 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006921}
6922
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006923// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006924ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006925 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6926 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006927}
6928
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006929/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006930ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006931 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6932 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006933 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006934 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006935
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006936 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6937 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006938 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006939 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006940
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006941 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006942 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006943 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6944 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006945}
6946
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006947ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006948Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006949 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006950 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6951 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6952
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006953 bool isFileScope
6954 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006955 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006956 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006957
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006958 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6959 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6960 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006961
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006962 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6963 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6964 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006965
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006966 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6967 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6968 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6969 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6970 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006971
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006972 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006973 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006974 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006975
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006976 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6977 // expressions are not lvalues.
6978
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006979 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006980}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006981
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006982ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006983 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006984 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6985 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006986 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6987 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006988 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006989 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006990
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006991 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6992 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6993 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006994 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006995 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6996 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6997
6998 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6999 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7000 if (!Dependent
7001 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7002 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7003 << TypeRange))
7004 return ExprError();
7005
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007006 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7007 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007008 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7009 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007010 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007011 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7012 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007013
7014 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7015 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7016 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7017 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7018 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7019 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7020 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7021 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7022 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7023 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7024 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7025 if(!AT)
7026 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7027 << CurrentType);
7028 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7029 } else
7030 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7031
7032 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7033 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7034 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7035 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7036 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7037 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7038 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7039 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7040
7041 // Record this array index.
7042 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7043 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7044 continue;
7045 }
7046
7047 // Offset of a field.
7048 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7049 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7050 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7051 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7052 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7053 continue;
7054 }
7055
7056 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7057 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7058 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7059 return ExprError();
7060
7061 // Look for the designated field.
7062 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7063 if (!RC)
7064 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7065 << CurrentType);
7066 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7067
7068 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7069 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7070 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7071 // (clause 9).
7072 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7073 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7074 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7075 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7076 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7077 << CurrentType))
7078 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7079 }
7080
7081 // Look for the field.
7082 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7083 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7084 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7085 if (!MemberDecl)
7086 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7087 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7088 OC.LocEnd));
7089
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007090 // C99 7.17p3:
7091 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7092 //
7093 // We diagnose this as an error.
7094 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7095 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7096 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7097 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7098 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7099 return ExprError();
7100 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007101
7102 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7103 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7104 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7105 do {
7106 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7107 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7108 }
7109
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007110 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7111 // the base class indirections.
7112 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7113 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007114 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007115 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7116 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7117 B != BEnd; ++B)
7118 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7119 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007120
7121 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007122 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7123 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7124 unsigned n = Path.size();
7125 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7126 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7127 } else {
7128 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7129 }
7130 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7131 }
7132
7133 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7134 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7135 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7136}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007137
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007138ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007139 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7140 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007141 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007142 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7143 unsigned NumComponents,
7144 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7145
7146 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7147 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7148 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7149 return ExprError();
7150
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007151 if (!ArgTInfo)
7152 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7153
7154 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7155 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007156}
7157
7158
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007159ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007160 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007161 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007162 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7163 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7164 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7165 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007166
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007167 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007168
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007169 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7170}
7171
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007172ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007173Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7174 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7175 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7176 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007177 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7178 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7179 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7180 return ExprError();
7181 }
7182
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007183 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007184 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007185}
7186
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007187
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007188ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007189 Expr *CondExpr,
7190 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007191 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007192 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7193
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007194 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007195 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007196 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007197 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007198 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007199 } else {
7200 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7201 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7202 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7203 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007204 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7205 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7206 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007207
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007208 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7209 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007210 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7211 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007212 }
7213
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007214 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007215 resType, RPLoc,
7216 resType->isDependentType(),
7217 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007218}
7219
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007220//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7221// Clang Extensions.
7222//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7223
7224/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007225void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007226 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7227 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7228 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007229 if (BlockScope)
7230 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7231 else
7232 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007233}
7234
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007235void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007236 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007237 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007238
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007239 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007240 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007241 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007242
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007243 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007244 QualType RetTy;
7245 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007246 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007247 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007248 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007249 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7250 } else {
7251 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007252 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007253 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007254
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007255 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007256
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007257 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7258 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7259 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007260 return;
7261 }
7262
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007263 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7264 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7265 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7266 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7267 return;
7268 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007269
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007270 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007271 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7272 // ^ * { ... }
7273 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007274 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7275 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007276
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007277 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007278 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007279 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7280 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7281 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7282 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007283 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7284 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7285 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7286 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7287 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007288 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007289 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007290
7291 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7292 // ^ fntype { ... }
7293 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7294 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7295 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7296 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7297 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7298 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7299 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007300 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007301 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007302 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007303
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007304 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7305 if (!Params.empty())
7306 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007307
7308 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007309 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007310
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007311 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007312 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7313 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7314 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7315 }
7316
7317 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7318 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007319 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007320 return;
7321
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007322 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7323 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7324
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007325 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007326 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7327 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7328
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007329 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007330 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7331 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7332 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7333
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007334 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007335 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007336 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007337}
7338
7339/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7340/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7341void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007342 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007343 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007344 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007345 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007346}
7347
7348/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7349/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007350ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007351 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007352 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7353 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7354 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007355
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007356 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007357
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007358 PopDeclContext();
7359
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007360 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007361 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7362 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007363
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007364 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007365 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007366
7367 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7368 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7369 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7370
7371 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7372 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7373
7374 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7375 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7376 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7377 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7378
7379 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7380 // preserve its sugar structure.
7381 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7382 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7383 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7384
7385 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7386 } else {
7387 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7388 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7389 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7390 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7391 FPT->isVariadic(),
7392 /*quals*/ 0,
7393 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7394 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7395 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7396 FPT->exception_begin(),
7397 Ext);
7398 }
7399
7400 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7401 } else {
7402 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7403 false, false, 0, 0,
7404 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7405 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007406
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007407 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007408 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7409 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007410 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007411
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007412 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007413 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007414 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007415
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007416 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007417
7418 bool Good = true;
7419 // Check goto/label use.
7420 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7421 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7422 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7423
7424 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7425 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007426 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7427 if (!L->isUsed())
7428 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007429 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007430 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007431
7432 // Emit error.
7433 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7434 Good = false;
7435 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007436 if (!Good) {
7437 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007438 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007439 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007440
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007441 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7442 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7443
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007444 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007445 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7446 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007447 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007448
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007449 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007450 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007451}
7452
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007453ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007454 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007455 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007456 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7457 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007458 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007459}
7460
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007461ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007462 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007463 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007464 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007465
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007466 // Get the va_list type
7467 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007468 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7469 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7470 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7471 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007472 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007473 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7474 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7475 } else {
7476 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7477 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007478 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007479 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007480 return ExprError();
7481 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007482
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007483 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7484 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007485 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7486 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007487 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007488 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007489
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007490 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007491 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007492
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007493 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7494 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007495}
7496
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007497ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007498 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7499 // pointers on the target.
7500 QualType Ty;
7501 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7502 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7503 else
7504 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7505
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007506 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007507}
7508
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007509static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007510 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007511 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7512 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007513
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007514 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7515 if (!PT)
7516 return;
7517
7518 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7519 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7520 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7521 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7522 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7523 return;
7524 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007525
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007526 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7527 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7528 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7529 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007530
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007531 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007532}
7533
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007534bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7535 SourceLocation Loc,
7536 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007537 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7538 bool *Complained) {
7539 if (Complained)
7540 *Complained = false;
7541
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007542 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7543 bool isInvalid = false;
7544 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007545 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007546
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007547 switch (ConvTy) {
7548 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7549 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007550 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007551 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7552 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007553 case IntToPointer:
7554 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7555 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007556 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007557 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007558 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7559 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007560 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7561 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7562 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007563 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7564 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7565 break;
7566 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007567 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7568 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7569 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7570 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7571 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7572 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7573 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7574 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7575 // C++ semantics.
7576 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7577 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7578 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007579 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7580 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007581 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007582 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007583 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007584 case IntToBlockPointer:
7585 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7586 break;
7587 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007588 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007589 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007590 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007591 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007592 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7593 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7594 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007595 case IncompatibleVectors:
7596 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7597 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007598 case Incompatible:
7599 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7600 isInvalid = true;
7601 break;
7602 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007603
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007604 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7605 switch (Action) {
7606 case AA_Assigning:
7607 case AA_Initializing:
7608 // The destination type comes first.
7609 FirstType = DstType;
7610 SecondType = SrcType;
7611 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007612
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007613 case AA_Returning:
7614 case AA_Passing:
7615 case AA_Converting:
7616 case AA_Sending:
7617 case AA_Casting:
7618 // The source type comes first.
7619 FirstType = SrcType;
7620 SecondType = DstType;
7621 break;
7622 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007623
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007624 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007625 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007626 if (Complained)
7627 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007628 return isInvalid;
7629}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007630
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007631bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007632 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7633 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7634 if (Result)
7635 *Result = ICEResult;
7636 return false;
7637 }
7638
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007639 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7640
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007641 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007642 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7643 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7644
7645 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7646 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7647 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7648 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7649 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7650 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7651 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007652
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007653 return true;
7654 }
7655
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007656 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7657 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007658
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007659 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7660 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7661 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007662
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007663 if (Result)
7664 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7665 return false;
7666}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007667
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007668void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007669Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007670 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7671 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007672}
7673
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007674void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007675Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7676 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7677 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7678 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007679
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007680 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7681 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7682 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7683 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7684 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007685 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007686 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7687 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7688 I != IEnd; ++I)
7689 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7690 }
7691
7692 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7693 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7694 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7695 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7696 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7697 I != IEnd; ++I)
7698 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7699 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007700 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007701
7702 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7703 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7704 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7705 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007706 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007707 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7708 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7709 ExprTemporaries.end());
7710
7711 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7712 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007713}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007714
7715/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7716///
7717/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7718/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7719/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7720/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7721///
7722/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7723///
7724/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7725void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7726 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007727
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007728 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007729 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007730
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007731 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7732 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7733 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7734 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007735 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007736 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007737 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007738 return;
7739 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007740
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007741 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7742 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007743
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007744 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7745 // an instantiation.
7746 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7747 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007748
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007749 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007750 case Unevaluated:
7751 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7752 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007753
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007754 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7755 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7756 // "used"; handle this below.
7757 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007758
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007759 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7760 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7761 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7762 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007763 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007764 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007765
7766 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7767 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7768 // containing expression is used.
7769 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007770 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007771
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007772 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007773 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007774 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007775 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007776 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7777 return;
7778 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7779 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007780 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007781 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007782 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007783 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7784 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007785
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007786 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007787 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007788 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007789 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007790 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7791 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007792 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7793 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7794 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007795 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007796 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007797 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7798 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007799 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007800 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007801 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007802 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007803 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007804 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7805 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7806 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7807 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7808 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007809 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007810 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007811 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007812 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007813 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7814 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7815 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007816 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007817 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007818 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7819 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007820
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007821 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7822 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7823 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7824 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7825 Loc));
7826 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007827 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007828 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007829 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7830 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7831 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007832 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007833 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7834 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007835
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007836 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007837
7838 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7839 if (CurContext != Function)
7840 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007841
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007842 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007843 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007844
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007845 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007846 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007847 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007848 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7849 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7850 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7851 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7852 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7853 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007854 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007855 }
7856 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007857
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007858 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007859
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007860 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007861 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007862 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007863}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007864
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007865namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007866 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007867 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007868 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007869 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7870 Sema &S;
7871 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007872
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007873 public:
7874 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007875
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007876 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007877
7878 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7879 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007880 };
7881}
7882
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007883bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7884 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007885 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7886 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7887 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007888
7889 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007890}
7891
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007892bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007893 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7894 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7895 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007896 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7897 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007898 }
7899
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007900 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007901}
7902
7903void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7904 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007905 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007906}
7907
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007908namespace {
7909 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7910 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7911 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7912 Sema &S;
7913
7914 public:
7915 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7916
7917 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7918
7919 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7920 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7921 }
7922
7923 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7924 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007925 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007926 }
7927
7928 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7929 if (E->getConstructor())
7930 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7931 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7932 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7933 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7934 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007935 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007936 }
7937
7938 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7939 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7940 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007941 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7942 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7943 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7944 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7945 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7946 }
7947
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007948 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007949 }
7950
7951 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7952 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007953 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007954 }
7955
7956 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7957 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7958 }
7959 };
7960}
7961
7962/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7963/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7964void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7965 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7966}
7967
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007968/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7969/// of the program being compiled.
7970///
7971/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007972/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007973/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7974/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7975/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7976/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007977/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007978/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007979///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007980/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7981/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7982/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7983/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007984bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007985 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7986 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7987 case Unevaluated:
7988 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7989 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007990
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007991 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007992 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007993 Diag(Loc, PD);
7994 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007995
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007996 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7997 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7998 break;
7999 }
8000
8001 return false;
8002}
8003
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008004bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8005 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8006 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8007 return false;
8008
8009 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8010 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8011 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8012 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008013
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008014 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008015 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008016 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8017 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008018 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008019 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8020 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8021 return true;
8022
8023 return false;
8024}
8025
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008026// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8027// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8028void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8029 SourceLocation Loc;
8030
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008031 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8032
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008033 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8034 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008035 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008036 return;
8037
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008038 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8039 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8040 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8041 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8042
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008043 // self = [<foo> init...]
8044 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8045 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8046 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8047
8048 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8049 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8050 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8051 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8052 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008053
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008054 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8055 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8056 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8057 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8058 return;
8059
8060 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8061 } else {
8062 // Not an assignment.
8063 return;
8064 }
8065
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008066 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008067 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008068
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008069 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008070 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008071 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008072 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8073 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8074 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008075}
8076
8077bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8078 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8079
8080 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008081 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008082
8083 QualType T = E->getType();
8084
8085 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8086 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8087 return true;
8088 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8089 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8090 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8091 return true;
8092 }
8093 }
8094
8095 return false;
8096}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008097
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008098ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8099 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008100 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008101 return ExprError();
8102
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008103 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008104 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008105
8106 return Owned(Sub);
8107}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008108
8109/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8110/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8111ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8112 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8113 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8114
8115 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8116 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8117 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8118 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8119 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8120 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8121 Specialization->getAccess());
8122 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8123 if (!E) return ExprError();
8124 return Owned(E);
8125 }
8126
8127 Diag(Loc, diag::err_cannot_determine_declared_type_of_overloaded_function)
8128 << E->getSourceRange();
8129 return ExprError();
8130 }
8131
8132 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8133 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8134
8135 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8136 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8137 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8138 return ExprError();
8139}